agora inbox for [email protected]  
help / color / mirror / Atom feed
[PATCH v2 1/4] pg_dump/pg_dumpall: bump minimum supported version to v10
353+ messages / 2 participants
[nested] [flat]

* [PATCH v2 1/4] pg_dump/pg_dumpall: bump minimum supported version to v10
@ 2026-04-17 17:15  Nathan Bossart <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Nathan Bossart @ 2026-04-17 17:15 UTC (permalink / raw)

---
 doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dump.sgml |  14 +-
 doc/src/sgml/runtime.sgml     |   2 +-
 src/bin/pg_dump/pg_dump.c     | 330 ++--------------------------------
 src/bin/pg_dump/pg_dumpall.c  |  32 +---
 4 files changed, 22 insertions(+), 356 deletions(-)

diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dump.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dump.sgml
index ae1bc14d2f2..64a3447e445 100644
--- a/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dump.sgml
+++ b/doc/src/sgml/ref/pg_dump.sgml
@@ -407,18 +407,6 @@ PostgreSQL documentation
         and there is no way to continue with the dump, so <application>pg_dump</application> has no choice
         but to abort the dump.
        </para>
-       <para>
-        To perform a parallel dump, the database server needs to support
-        synchronized snapshots, a feature that was introduced in
-        <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> 9.2 for primary servers and 10
-        for standbys. With this feature, database clients can ensure they see
-        the same data set even though they use different connections.
-        <command>pg_dump -j</command> uses multiple database connections; it
-        connects to the database once with the leader process and once again
-        for each worker job. Without the synchronized snapshot feature, the
-        different worker jobs wouldn't be guaranteed to see the same data in
-        each connection, which could lead to an inconsistent backup.
-       </para>
       </listitem>
      </varlistentry>
 
@@ -1718,7 +1706,7 @@ CREATE DATABASE foo WITH TEMPLATE template0;
    <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> server versions newer than
    <application>pg_dump</application>'s version.  <application>pg_dump</application> can also
    dump from <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> servers older than its own version.
-   (Currently, servers back to version 9.2 are supported.)
+   (Currently, servers back to version 10 are supported.)
    However, <application>pg_dump</application> cannot dump from
    <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> servers newer than its own major version;
    it will refuse to even try, rather than risk making an invalid dump.
diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/runtime.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/runtime.sgml
index b01e74638c4..3fa6cdf3a5e 100644
--- a/doc/src/sgml/runtime.sgml
+++ b/doc/src/sgml/runtime.sgml
@@ -1776,7 +1776,7 @@ $ <userinput>kill -INT `head -1 /usr/local/pgsql/data/postmaster.pid`</userinput
     version of
     <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>, to take advantage of enhancements
     that might have been made in these programs.  Current releases of the
-    dump programs can read data from any server version back to 9.2.
+    dump programs can read data from any server version back to 10.
    </para>
 
    <para>
diff --git a/src/bin/pg_dump/pg_dump.c b/src/bin/pg_dump/pg_dump.c
index d56dcc701ce..eed9aaeb7c1 100644
--- a/src/bin/pg_dump/pg_dump.c
+++ b/src/bin/pg_dump/pg_dump.c
@@ -977,10 +977,10 @@ main(int argc, char **argv)
 
 
 	/*
-	 * We allow the server to be back to 9.2, and up to any minor release of
+	 * We allow the server to be back to 10, and up to any minor release of
 	 * our own major version.  (See also version check in pg_dumpall.c.)
 	 */
-	fout->minRemoteVersion = 90200;
+	fout->minRemoteVersion = 100000;
 	fout->maxRemoteVersion = (PG_VERSION_NUM / 100) * 100 + 99;
 
 	fout->numWorkers = numWorkers;
@@ -1491,9 +1491,7 @@ setup_connection(Archive *AH, const char *dumpencoding,
 	 * Disable timeouts if supported.
 	 */
 	ExecuteSqlStatement(AH, "SET statement_timeout = 0");
-	if (AH->remoteVersion >= 90300)
 		ExecuteSqlStatement(AH, "SET lock_timeout = 0");
-	if (AH->remoteVersion >= 90600)
 		ExecuteSqlStatement(AH, "SET idle_in_transaction_session_timeout = 0");
 	if (AH->remoteVersion >= 170000)
 		ExecuteSqlStatement(AH, "SET transaction_timeout = 0");
@@ -1507,13 +1505,10 @@ setup_connection(Archive *AH, const char *dumpencoding,
 	/*
 	 * Adjust row-security mode, if supported.
 	 */
-	if (AH->remoteVersion >= 90500)
-	{
 		if (dopt->enable_row_security)
 			ExecuteSqlStatement(AH, "SET row_security = on");
 		else
 			ExecuteSqlStatement(AH, "SET row_security = off");
-	}
 
 	/*
 	 * For security reasons, we restrict the expansion of non-system views and
@@ -1568,11 +1563,7 @@ setup_connection(Archive *AH, const char *dumpencoding,
 		destroyPQExpBuffer(query);
 	}
 	else if (AH->numWorkers > 1)
-	{
-		if (AH->isStandby && AH->remoteVersion < 100000)
-			pg_fatal("parallel dumps from standby servers are not supported by this server version");
 		AH->sync_snapshot_id = get_synchronized_snapshot(AH);
-	}
 }
 
 /* Set up connection for a parallel worker process */
@@ -1964,12 +1955,7 @@ checkExtensionMembership(DumpableObject *dobj, Archive *fout)
 	if (fout->dopt->binary_upgrade)
 		dobj->dump = ext->dobj.dump;
 	else
-	{
-		if (fout->remoteVersion < 90600)
-			dobj->dump = DUMP_COMPONENT_NONE;
-		else
 			dobj->dump = ext->dobj.dump_contains & (DUMP_COMPONENT_ACL);
-	}
 
 	return true;
 }
@@ -2000,11 +1986,10 @@ selectDumpableNamespace(NamespaceInfo *nsinfo, Archive *fout)
 			simple_oid_list_member(&schema_include_oids,
 								   nsinfo->dobj.catId.oid) ?
 			DUMP_COMPONENT_ALL : DUMP_COMPONENT_NONE;
-	else if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600 &&
-			 strcmp(nsinfo->dobj.name, "pg_catalog") == 0)
+	else if (strcmp(nsinfo->dobj.name, "pg_catalog") == 0)
 	{
 		/*
-		 * In 9.6 and above, we dump out any ACLs defined in pg_catalog, if
+		 * We dump out any ACLs defined in pg_catalog, if
 		 * they are interesting (and not the original ACLs which were set at
 		 * initdb time, see pg_init_privs).
 		 */
@@ -2213,8 +2198,7 @@ selectDumpableProcLang(ProcLangInfo *plang, Archive *fout)
 	else
 	{
 		if (plang->dobj.catId.oid <= g_last_builtin_oid)
-			plang->dobj.dump = fout->remoteVersion < 90600 ?
-				DUMP_COMPONENT_NONE : DUMP_COMPONENT_ACL;
+			plang->dobj.dump = DUMP_COMPONENT_ACL;
 		else
 			plang->dobj.dump = DUMP_COMPONENT_ALL;
 	}
@@ -2231,13 +2215,6 @@ selectDumpableProcLang(ProcLangInfo *plang, Archive *fout)
 static void
 selectDumpableAccessMethod(AccessMethodInfo *method, Archive *fout)
 {
-	/* see getAccessMethods() comment about v9.6. */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion < 90600)
-	{
-		method->dobj.dump = DUMP_COMPONENT_NONE;
-		return;
-	}
-
 	if (checkExtensionMembership(&method->dobj, fout))
 		return;					/* extension membership overrides all else */
 
@@ -3123,10 +3100,6 @@ buildMatViewRefreshDependencies(Archive *fout)
 				i_objid,
 				i_refobjid;
 
-	/* No Mat Views before 9.3. */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion < 90300)
-		return;
-
 	query = createPQExpBuffer();
 
 	appendPQExpBufferStr(query, "WITH RECURSIVE w AS "
@@ -3325,10 +3298,7 @@ dumpDatabase(Archive *fout)
 						 "datcollate, datctype, datfrozenxid, "
 						 "datacl, acldefault('d', datdba) AS acldefault, "
 						 "datistemplate, datconnlimit, ");
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90300)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(dbQry, "datminmxid, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(dbQry, "0 AS datminmxid, ");
 	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 170000)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(dbQry, "datlocprovider, datlocale, datcollversion, ");
 	else if (fout->remoteVersion >= 150000)
@@ -3670,17 +3640,11 @@ dumpDatabase(Archive *fout)
 					ii_oid,
 					ii_relminmxid;
 
-		if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90300)
 			appendPQExpBuffer(loFrozenQry, "SELECT relfrozenxid, relminmxid, relfilenode, oid\n"
 							  "FROM pg_catalog.pg_class\n"
 							  "WHERE oid IN (%u, %u, %u, %u);\n",
 							  LargeObjectRelationId, LargeObjectLOidPNIndexId,
 							  LargeObjectMetadataRelationId, LargeObjectMetadataOidIndexId);
-		else
-			appendPQExpBuffer(loFrozenQry, "SELECT relfrozenxid, 0 AS relminmxid, relfilenode, oid\n"
-							  "FROM pg_catalog.pg_class\n"
-							  "WHERE oid IN (%u, %u);\n",
-							  LargeObjectRelationId, LargeObjectLOidPNIndexId);
 
 		lo_res = ExecuteSqlQuery(fout, loFrozenQry->data, PGRES_TUPLES_OK);
 
@@ -4243,10 +4207,6 @@ getPolicies(Archive *fout, TableInfo tblinfo[], int numTables)
 				j,
 				ntups;
 
-	/* No policies before 9.5 */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion < 90500)
-		return;
-
 	/* Skip if --no-policies was specified */
 	if (dopt->no_policies)
 		return;
@@ -4316,10 +4276,7 @@ getPolicies(Archive *fout, TableInfo tblinfo[], int numTables)
 
 	printfPQExpBuffer(query,
 					  "SELECT pol.oid, pol.tableoid, pol.polrelid, pol.polname, pol.polcmd, ");
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 100000)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query, "pol.polpermissive, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query, "'t' as polpermissive, ");
 	appendPQExpBuffer(query,
 					  "CASE WHEN pol.polroles = '{0}' THEN NULL ELSE "
 					  "   pg_catalog.array_to_string(ARRAY(SELECT pg_catalog.quote_ident(rolname) from pg_catalog.pg_roles WHERE oid = ANY(pol.polroles)), ', ') END AS polroles, "
@@ -4534,7 +4491,7 @@ getPublications(Archive *fout)
 	int			i,
 				ntups;
 
-	if (dopt->no_publications || fout->remoteVersion < 100000)
+	if (dopt->no_publications)
 		return;
 
 	query = createPQExpBuffer();
@@ -4897,7 +4854,7 @@ getPublicationTables(Archive *fout, TableInfo tblinfo[], int numTables)
 				j,
 				ntups;
 
-	if (dopt->no_publications || fout->remoteVersion < 100000)
+	if (dopt->no_publications)
 		return;
 
 	query = createPQExpBuffer();
@@ -5187,7 +5144,7 @@ getSubscriptions(Archive *fout)
 	int			i,
 				ntups;
 
-	if (dopt->no_subscriptions || fout->remoteVersion < 100000)
+	if (dopt->no_subscriptions)
 		return;
 
 	if (!is_superuser(fout))
@@ -6675,24 +6632,12 @@ getAccessMethods(Archive *fout)
 	query = createPQExpBuffer();
 
 	/*
-	 * Select all access methods from pg_am table.  v9.6 introduced CREATE
-	 * ACCESS METHOD, so earlier versions usually have only built-in access
-	 * methods.  v9.6 also changed the access method API, replacing dozens of
-	 * pg_am columns with amhandler.  Even if a user created an access method
-	 * by "INSERT INTO pg_am", we have no way to translate pre-v9.6 pg_am
-	 * columns to a v9.6+ CREATE ACCESS METHOD.  Hence, before v9.6, read
-	 * pg_am just to facilitate findAccessMethodByOid() providing the
-	 * OID-to-name mapping.
+	 * Select all access methods from pg_am table.
 	 */
 	appendPQExpBufferStr(query, "SELECT tableoid, oid, amname, ");
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "amtype, "
 							 "amhandler::pg_catalog.regproc AS amhandler ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "'i'::pg_catalog.\"char\" AS amtype, "
-							 "'-'::pg_catalog.regproc AS amhandler ");
 	appendPQExpBufferStr(query, "FROM pg_am");
 
 	res = ExecuteSqlQuery(fout, query->data, PGRES_TUPLES_OK);
@@ -6878,15 +6823,12 @@ getAggregates(Archive *fout)
 	int			i_proowner;
 	int			i_aggacl;
 	int			i_acldefault;
+	const char *agg_check;
 
 	/*
 	 * Find all interesting aggregates.  See comment in getFuncs() for the
 	 * rationale behind the filtering logic.
 	 */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600)
-	{
-		const char *agg_check;
-
 		agg_check = (fout->remoteVersion >= 110000 ? "p.prokind = 'a'"
 					 : "p.proisagg");
 
@@ -6916,29 +6858,6 @@ getAggregates(Archive *fout)
 								 "refclassid = 'pg_extension'::regclass AND "
 								 "deptype = 'e')");
 		appendPQExpBufferChar(query, ')');
-	}
-	else
-	{
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query, "SELECT tableoid, oid, proname AS aggname, "
-							 "pronamespace AS aggnamespace, "
-							 "pronargs, proargtypes, "
-							 "proowner, "
-							 "proacl AS aggacl, "
-							 "acldefault('f', proowner) AS acldefault "
-							 "FROM pg_proc p "
-							 "WHERE proisagg AND ("
-							 "pronamespace != "
-							 "(SELECT oid FROM pg_namespace "
-							 "WHERE nspname = 'pg_catalog')");
-		if (dopt->binary_upgrade)
-			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-								 " OR EXISTS(SELECT 1 FROM pg_depend WHERE "
-								 "classid = 'pg_proc'::regclass AND "
-								 "objid = p.oid AND "
-								 "refclassid = 'pg_extension'::regclass AND "
-								 "deptype = 'e')");
-		appendPQExpBufferChar(query, ')');
-	}
 
 	res = ExecuteSqlQuery(fout, query->data, PGRES_TUPLES_OK);
 
@@ -7021,6 +6940,7 @@ getFuncs(Archive *fout)
 	int			i_prorettype;
 	int			i_proacl;
 	int			i_acldefault;
+	const char *not_agg_check;
 
 	/*
 	 * Find all interesting functions.  This is a bit complicated:
@@ -7039,14 +6959,10 @@ getFuncs(Archive *fout)
 	 * include them, since we want to dump extension members individually in
 	 * that mode.  Also, if they are used by casts or transforms then we need
 	 * to gather the information about them, though they won't be dumped if
-	 * they are built-in.  Also, in 9.6 and up, include functions in
+	 * they are built-in.  Also, include functions in
 	 * pg_catalog if they have an ACL different from what's shown in
 	 * pg_init_privs (so we have to join to pg_init_privs; annoying).
 	 */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600)
-	{
-		const char *not_agg_check;
-
 		not_agg_check = (fout->remoteVersion >= 110000 ? "p.prokind <> 'a'"
 						 : "NOT p.proisagg");
 
@@ -7090,46 +7006,6 @@ getFuncs(Archive *fout)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "\n  OR p.proacl IS DISTINCT FROM pip.initprivs");
 		appendPQExpBufferChar(query, ')');
-	}
-	else
-	{
-		appendPQExpBuffer(query,
-						  "SELECT tableoid, oid, proname, prolang, "
-						  "pronargs, proargtypes, prorettype, proacl, "
-						  "acldefault('f', proowner) AS acldefault, "
-						  "pronamespace, "
-						  "proowner "
-						  "FROM pg_proc p "
-						  "WHERE NOT proisagg"
-						  "\n  AND NOT EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM pg_depend "
-						  "WHERE classid = 'pg_proc'::regclass AND "
-						  "objid = p.oid AND deptype = 'i')"
-						  "\n  AND ("
-						  "\n  pronamespace != "
-						  "(SELECT oid FROM pg_namespace "
-						  "WHERE nspname = 'pg_catalog')"
-						  "\n  OR EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM pg_cast"
-						  "\n  WHERE pg_cast.oid > '%u'::oid"
-						  "\n  AND p.oid = pg_cast.castfunc)",
-						  g_last_builtin_oid);
-
-		if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90500)
-			appendPQExpBuffer(query,
-							  "\n  OR EXISTS (SELECT 1 FROM pg_transform"
-							  "\n  WHERE pg_transform.oid > '%u'::oid"
-							  "\n  AND (p.oid = pg_transform.trffromsql"
-							  "\n  OR p.oid = pg_transform.trftosql))",
-							  g_last_builtin_oid);
-
-		if (dopt->binary_upgrade)
-			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-								 "\n  OR EXISTS(SELECT 1 FROM pg_depend WHERE "
-								 "classid = 'pg_proc'::regclass AND "
-								 "objid = p.oid AND "
-								 "refclassid = 'pg_extension'::regclass AND "
-								 "deptype = 'e')");
-		appendPQExpBufferChar(query, ')');
-	}
 
 	res = ExecuteSqlQuery(fout, query->data, PGRES_TUPLES_OK);
 
@@ -7378,64 +7254,31 @@ getTables(Archive *fout, int *numTables)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "c.relhasoids, ");
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90300)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "c.relispopulated, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "'t' as relispopulated, ");
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90400)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "c.relreplident, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "'d' AS relreplident, ");
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90500)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "c.relrowsecurity, c.relforcerowsecurity, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "false AS relrowsecurity, "
-							 "false AS relforcerowsecurity, ");
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90300)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "c.relminmxid, tc.relminmxid AS tminmxid, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "0 AS relminmxid, 0 AS tminmxid, ");
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90300)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "array_remove(array_remove(c.reloptions,'check_option=local'),'check_option=cascaded') AS reloptions, "
 							 "CASE WHEN 'check_option=local' = ANY (c.reloptions) THEN 'LOCAL'::text "
 							 "WHEN 'check_option=cascaded' = ANY (c.reloptions) THEN 'CASCADED'::text ELSE NULL END AS checkoption, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "c.reloptions, NULL AS checkoption, ");
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "am.amname, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "NULL AS amname, ");
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "(d.deptype = 'i') IS TRUE AS is_identity_sequence, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "false AS is_identity_sequence, ");
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 100000)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "c.relispartition AS ispartition ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "false AS ispartition ");
 
 	/*
 	 * Left join to pg_depend to pick up dependency info linking sequences to
@@ -7453,9 +7296,8 @@ getTables(Archive *fout, int *numTables)
 						 "LEFT JOIN pg_tablespace tsp ON (tsp.oid = c.reltablespace)\n");
 
 	/*
-	 * In 9.6 and up, left join to pg_am to pick up the amname.
+	 * Left join to pg_am to pick up the amname.
 	 */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "LEFT JOIN pg_am am ON (c.relam = am.oid)\n");
 
@@ -8028,12 +7870,8 @@ getIndexes(Archive *fout, TableInfo tblinfo[], int numTables)
 						 "t.reloptions AS indreloptions, ");
 
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90400)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "i.indisreplident, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "false AS indisreplident, ");
 
 	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 110000)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
@@ -8318,10 +8156,6 @@ getExtendedStatistics(Archive *fout)
 	int			i_stattarget;
 	int			i;
 
-	/* Extended statistics were new in v10 */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion < 100000)
-		return;
-
 	query = createPQExpBuffer();
 
 	if (fout->remoteVersion < 130000)
@@ -8988,10 +8822,6 @@ getEventTriggers(Archive *fout)
 				i_evtenabled;
 	int			ntups;
 
-	/* Before 9.3, there are no event triggers */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion < 90300)
-		return;
-
 	query = createPQExpBuffer();
 
 	appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
@@ -9258,10 +9088,6 @@ getTransforms(Archive *fout)
 	int			i_trffromsql;
 	int			i_trftosql;
 
-	/* Transforms didn't exist pre-9.5 */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion < 90500)
-		return;
-
 	query = createPQExpBuffer();
 
 	appendPQExpBufferStr(query, "SELECT tableoid, oid, "
@@ -9489,12 +9315,8 @@ getTableAttrs(Archive *fout, TableInfo *tblinfo, int numTables)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(q,
 							 "'' AS attcompression,\n");
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 100000)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(q,
 							 "a.attidentity,\n");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(q,
-							 "'' AS attidentity,\n");
 
 	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 110000)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(q,
@@ -10897,8 +10719,6 @@ getAdditionalACLs(Archive *fout)
 	PQclear(res);
 
 	/* Fetch initial-privileges data */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600)
-	{
 		printfPQExpBuffer(query,
 						  "SELECT objoid, classoid, objsubid, privtype, initprivs "
 						  "FROM pg_init_privs");
@@ -10966,7 +10786,6 @@ getAdditionalACLs(Archive *fout)
 			}
 		}
 		PQclear(res);
-	}
 
 	destroyPQExpBuffer(query);
 }
@@ -11141,15 +10960,6 @@ fetchAttributeStats(Archive *fout)
 	static bool restarted;
 	int			max_rels = MAX_ATTR_STATS_RELS;
 
-	/*
-	 * Our query for retrieving statistics for multiple relations uses WITH
-	 * ORDINALITY and multi-argument UNNEST(), both of which were introduced
-	 * in v9.4.  For older versions, we resort to gathering statistics for a
-	 * single relation at a time.
-	 */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion < 90400)
-		max_rels = 1;
-
 	/* If we're just starting, set our TOC pointer. */
 	if (!te)
 		te = AH->toc->next;
@@ -11320,16 +11130,11 @@ dumpRelationStats_dumper(Archive *fout, const void *userArg, const TocEntry *te)
 		 * The results must be in the order of the relations supplied in the
 		 * parameters to ensure we remain in sync as we walk through the TOC.
 		 *
-		 * For v9.4 through v18, the redundant filter clause on s.tablename =
+		 * For versions before 19, the redundant filter clause on s.tablename =
 		 * ANY(...) seems sufficient to convince the planner to use
 		 * pg_class_relname_nsp_index, which avoids a full scan of pg_stats.
 		 * In newer versions, pg_stats returns the table OIDs, eliminating the
 		 * need for that hack.
-		 *
-		 * Our query for retrieving statistics for multiple relations uses
-		 * WITH ORDINALITY and multi-argument UNNEST(), both of which were
-		 * introduced in v9.4.  For older versions, we resort to gathering
-		 * statistics for a single relation at a time.
 		 */
 		if (fout->remoteVersion >= 190000)
 			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
@@ -11337,7 +11142,7 @@ dumpRelationStats_dumper(Archive *fout, const void *userArg, const TocEntry *te)
 								 "JOIN unnest($1) WITH ORDINALITY AS u (tableid, ord) "
 								 "ON s.tableid = u.tableid "
 								 "ORDER BY u.ord, s.attname, s.inherited");
-		else if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90400)
+		else
 			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 								 "FROM pg_catalog.pg_stats s "
 								 "JOIN unnest($1, $2) WITH ORDINALITY AS u (schemaname, tablename, ord) "
@@ -11345,12 +11150,6 @@ dumpRelationStats_dumper(Archive *fout, const void *userArg, const TocEntry *te)
 								 "AND s.tablename = u.tablename "
 								 "WHERE s.tablename = ANY($2) "
 								 "ORDER BY u.ord, s.attname, s.inherited");
-		else
-			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-								 "FROM pg_catalog.pg_stats s "
-								 "WHERE s.schemaname = $1[1] "
-								 "AND s.tablename = $2[1] "
-								 "ORDER BY s.attname, s.inherited");
 
 		ExecuteSqlStatement(fout, query->data);
 
@@ -13672,19 +13471,11 @@ dumpFunc(Archive *fout, const FuncInfo *finfo)
 							 "pg_catalog.pg_get_function_result(p.oid) AS funcresult,\n"
 							 "proleakproof,\n");
 
-		if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90500)
 			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 								 "array_to_string(protrftypes, ' ') AS protrftypes,\n");
-		else
-			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-								 "NULL AS protrftypes,\n");
 
-		if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600)
 			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 								 "proparallel,\n");
-		else
-			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-								 "'u' AS proparallel,\n");
 
 		if (fout->remoteVersion >= 110000)
 			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
@@ -15174,14 +14965,9 @@ dumpCollation(Archive *fout, const CollInfo *collinfo)
 	/* Get collation-specific details */
 	appendPQExpBufferStr(query, "SELECT ");
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 100000)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 							 "collprovider, "
 							 "collversion, ");
-	else
-		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-							 "'c' AS collprovider, "
-							 "NULL AS collversion, ");
 
 	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 120000)
 		appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
@@ -15588,7 +15374,6 @@ dumpAgg(Archive *fout, const AggInfo *agginfo)
 							 "pg_catalog.pg_get_function_arguments(p.oid) AS funcargs,\n"
 							 "pg_catalog.pg_get_function_identity_arguments(p.oid) AS funciargs,\n");
 
-		if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90400)
 			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 								 "aggkind,\n"
 								 "aggmtransfn,\n"
@@ -15600,31 +15385,12 @@ dumpAgg(Archive *fout, const AggInfo *agginfo)
 								 "aggtransspace,\n"
 								 "aggmtransspace,\n"
 								 "aggminitval,\n");
-		else
-			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-								 "'n' AS aggkind,\n"
-								 "'-' AS aggmtransfn,\n"
-								 "'-' AS aggminvtransfn,\n"
-								 "'-' AS aggmfinalfn,\n"
-								 "0 AS aggmtranstype,\n"
-								 "false AS aggfinalextra,\n"
-								 "false AS aggmfinalextra,\n"
-								 "0 AS aggtransspace,\n"
-								 "0 AS aggmtransspace,\n"
-								 "NULL AS aggminitval,\n");
 
-		if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600)
 			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 								 "aggcombinefn,\n"
 								 "aggserialfn,\n"
 								 "aggdeserialfn,\n"
 								 "proparallel,\n");
-		else
-			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-								 "'-' AS aggcombinefn,\n"
-								 "'-' AS aggserialfn,\n"
-								 "'-' AS aggdeserialfn,\n"
-								 "'u' AS proparallel,\n");
 
 		if (fout->remoteVersion >= 110000)
 			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
@@ -17084,8 +16850,6 @@ dumpTable(Archive *fout, const TableInfo *tbinfo)
 			appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
 								 "PREPARE getColumnACLs(pg_catalog.oid) AS\n");
 
-			if (fout->remoteVersion >= 90600)
-			{
 				/*
 				 * In principle we should call acldefault('c', relowner) to
 				 * get the default ACL for a column.  However, we don't
@@ -17110,17 +16874,6 @@ dumpTable(Archive *fout, const TableInfo *tbinfo)
 									 "NOT at.attisdropped "
 									 "AND (at.attacl IS NOT NULL OR pip.initprivs IS NOT NULL) "
 									 "ORDER BY at.attnum");
-			}
-			else
-			{
-				appendPQExpBufferStr(query,
-									 "SELECT attname, attacl, '{}' AS acldefault, "
-									 "NULL AS privtype, NULL AS initprivs "
-									 "FROM pg_catalog.pg_attribute "
-									 "WHERE attrelid = $1 AND NOT attisdropped "
-									 "AND attacl IS NOT NULL "
-									 "ORDER BY attnum");
-			}
 
 			ExecuteSqlStatement(fout, query->data);
 
@@ -19410,16 +19163,10 @@ collectSequences(Archive *fout)
 	const char *query;
 
 	/*
-	 * Before Postgres 10, sequence metadata is in the sequence itself.  With
-	 * some extra effort, we might be able to use the sorted table for those
-	 * versions, but for now it seems unlikely to be worth it.
-	 *
 	 * Since version 18, we can gather the sequence data in this query with
 	 * pg_get_sequence_data(), but we only do so for non-schema-only dumps.
 	 */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion < 100000)
-		return;
-	else if (fout->remoteVersion < 180000 ||
+	if (fout->remoteVersion < 180000 ||
 			 (!fout->dopt->dumpData && !fout->dopt->sequence_data))
 		query = "SELECT seqrelid, format_type(seqtypid, NULL), "
 			"seqstart, seqincrement, "
@@ -19477,59 +19224,20 @@ dumpSequence(Archive *fout, const TableInfo *tbinfo)
 	PQExpBuffer delqry = createPQExpBuffer();
 	char	   *qseqname;
 	TableInfo  *owning_tab = NULL;
+	SequenceItem key = {0};
 
 	qseqname = pg_strdup(fmtId(tbinfo->dobj.name));
 
 	/*
-	 * For versions >= 10, the sequence information is gathered in a sorted
+	 * The sequence information is gathered in a sorted
 	 * table before any calls to dumpSequence().  See collectSequences() for
 	 * more information.
 	 */
-	if (fout->remoteVersion >= 100000)
-	{
-		SequenceItem key = {0};
-
 		Assert(sequences);
 
 		key.oid = tbinfo->dobj.catId.oid;
 		seq = bsearch(&key, sequences, nsequences,
 					  sizeof(SequenceItem), SequenceItemCmp);
-	}
-	else
-	{
-		PGresult   *res;
-
-		/*
-		 * Before PostgreSQL 10, sequence metadata is in the sequence itself.
-		 *
-		 * Note: it might seem that 'bigint' potentially needs to be
-		 * schema-qualified, but actually that's a keyword.
-		 */
-		appendPQExpBuffer(query,
-						  "SELECT 'bigint' AS sequence_type, "
-						  "start_value, increment_by, max_value, min_value, "
-						  "cache_value, is_cycled FROM %s",
-						  fmtQualifiedDumpable(tbinfo));
-
-		res = ExecuteSqlQuery(fout, query->data, PGRES_TUPLES_OK);
-
-		if (PQntuples(res) != 1)
-			pg_fatal(ngettext("query to get data of sequence \"%s\" returned %d row (expected 1)",
-							  "query to get data of sequence \"%s\" returned %d rows (expected 1)",
-							  PQntuples(res)),
-					 tbinfo->dobj.name, PQntuples(res));
-
-		seq = pg_malloc0_object(SequenceItem);
-		seq->seqtype = parse_sequence_type(PQgetvalue(res, 0, 0));
-		seq->startv = strtoi64(PQgetvalue(res, 0, 1), NULL, 10);
-		seq->incby = strtoi64(PQgetvalue(res, 0, 2), NULL, 10);
-		seq->maxv = strtoi64(PQgetvalue(res, 0, 3), NULL, 10);
-		seq->minv = strtoi64(PQgetvalue(res, 0, 4), NULL, 10);
-		seq->cache = strtoi64(PQgetvalue(res, 0, 5), NULL, 10);
-		seq->cycled = (strcmp(PQgetvalue(res, 0, 6), "t") == 0);
-
-		PQclear(res);
-	}
 
 	/* Calculate default limits for a sequence of this type */
 	is_ascending = (seq->incby >= 0);
@@ -19708,8 +19416,6 @@ dumpSequence(Archive *fout, const TableInfo *tbinfo)
 					 tbinfo->dobj.namespace->dobj.name, tbinfo->rolname,
 					 tbinfo->dobj.catId, 0, tbinfo->dobj.dumpId);
 
-	if (fout->remoteVersion < 100000)
-		pg_free(seq);
 	destroyPQExpBuffer(query);
 	destroyPQExpBuffer(delqry);
 	free(qseqname);
diff --git a/src/bin/pg_dump/pg_dumpall.c b/src/bin/pg_dump/pg_dumpall.c
index c1f43113c53..5b10f7122b7 100644
--- a/src/bin/pg_dump/pg_dumpall.c
+++ b/src/bin/pg_dump/pg_dumpall.c
@@ -693,11 +693,11 @@ main(int argc, char *argv[])
 		fout->verbose = verbose;
 
 		/*
-		 * We allow the server to be back to 9.2, and up to any minor release
+		 * We allow the server to be back to 10, and up to any minor release
 		 * of our own major version.  (See also version check in
 		 * pg_dumpall.c.)
 		 */
-		fout->minRemoteVersion = 90200;
+		fout->minRemoteVersion = 100000;
 		fout->maxRemoteVersion = (PG_VERSION_NUM / 100) * 100 + 99;
 		fout->numWorkers = 1;
 
@@ -954,17 +954,11 @@ dropRoles(PGconn *conn)
 	int			i_rolname;
 	int			i;
 
-	if (server_version >= 90600)
 		printfPQExpBuffer(buf,
 						  "SELECT rolname "
 						  "FROM %s "
 						  "WHERE rolname !~ '^pg_' "
 						  "ORDER BY 1", role_catalog);
-	else
-		printfPQExpBuffer(buf,
-						  "SELECT rolname "
-						  "FROM %s "
-						  "ORDER BY 1", role_catalog);
 
 	res = executeQuery(conn, buf->data);
 
@@ -1041,7 +1035,6 @@ dumpRoles(PGconn *conn)
 	 * Notes: rolconfig is dumped later, and pg_authid must be used for
 	 * extracting rolcomment regardless of role_catalog.
 	 */
-	if (server_version >= 90600)
 		printfPQExpBuffer(buf,
 						  "SELECT oid, rolname, rolsuper, rolinherit, "
 						  "rolcreaterole, rolcreatedb, "
@@ -1052,27 +1045,6 @@ dumpRoles(PGconn *conn)
 						  "FROM %s "
 						  "WHERE rolname !~ '^pg_' "
 						  "ORDER BY 2", role_catalog);
-	else if (server_version >= 90500)
-		printfPQExpBuffer(buf,
-						  "SELECT oid, rolname, rolsuper, rolinherit, "
-						  "rolcreaterole, rolcreatedb, "
-						  "rolcanlogin, rolconnlimit, rolpassword, "
-						  "rolvaliduntil, rolreplication, rolbypassrls, "
-						  "pg_catalog.shobj_description(oid, 'pg_authid') as rolcomment, "
-						  "rolname = current_user AS is_current_user "
-						  "FROM %s "
-						  "ORDER BY 2", role_catalog);
-	else
-		printfPQExpBuffer(buf,
-						  "SELECT oid, rolname, rolsuper, rolinherit, "
-						  "rolcreaterole, rolcreatedb, "
-						  "rolcanlogin, rolconnlimit, rolpassword, "
-						  "rolvaliduntil, rolreplication, "
-						  "false as rolbypassrls, "
-						  "pg_catalog.shobj_description(oid, 'pg_authid') as rolcomment, "
-						  "rolname = current_user AS is_current_user "
-						  "FROM %s "
-						  "ORDER BY 2", role_catalog);
 
 	res = executeQuery(conn, buf->data);
 
-- 
2.50.1 (Apple Git-155)


--CT89ko5pLUrsvFtH
Content-Type: text/plain; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename=v2-0002-pg_upgrade-bump-minimum-supported-version-to-v10.patch



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-03 14:03  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:03 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 167 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 118 insertions(+), 49 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index e23b366a87d..866341c2cfb 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2570,11 +2596,6 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subid = form->oid;
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
 	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
@@ -2583,20 +2604,68 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v3-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by:
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--3eAVwo4vDNlHc8RC--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication
@ 2026-07-03 14:46  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-03 14:46 UTC (permalink / raw)

Apply the same RangeVarGetRelidExtended() style retry loop to
AlterPublication()'s tables/schemas branch that was added for subscriptions
in commit XXXX.

Previously, this branch resolved the publication name and checked ownership
at the top of AlterPublication(), then locked and re-read by OID. This left a
window where concurrent DDL could have modified the ownership and/or the name
resolution

Now the tables/schemas branch has its own complete retry loop: name
resolution, ownership check, and lock acquisition all inside the loop.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c | 105 +++++++++++++++++--------
 1 file changed, 72 insertions(+), 33 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
index 440adb356ad..dfd707bc7d7 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/publicationcmds.c
@@ -39,6 +39,7 @@
 #include "parser/parse_relation.h"
 #include "rewrite/rewriteHandler.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/inval.h"
@@ -1662,54 +1663,92 @@ AlterPublication(ParseState *pstate, AlterPublicationStmt *stmt)
 
 	rel = table_open(PublicationRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
+	if (stmt->options)
+	{
+		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->pubname)));
+		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			ereport(ERROR,
+					(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+					 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+							stmt->pubname)));
 
-	pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+		pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
-					   stmt->pubname);
+		/* must be owner */
+		if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubform->oid,
+							   GetUserId()))
+			aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+						   stmt->pubname);
 
-	if (stmt->options)
 		AlterPublicationOptions(pstate, stmt, rel, tup);
+	}
 	else
 	{
 		List	   *relations = NIL;
 		List	   *exceptrelations = NIL;
 		List	   *schemaidlist = NIL;
-		Oid			pubid = pubform->oid;
+		Oid			pubid;
 
-		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
-								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+		/*
+		 * Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it.
+		 *
+		 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+		 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation
+		 * messages arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the
+		 * lock held across retries and only release it if the name resolves
+		 * to a different OID on the next iteration.
+		 */
+		{
+			Oid			oldPubId = InvalidOid;
+			bool		retry = false;
 
-		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
+			for (;;)
+			{
+				uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-		heap_freetuple(tup);
+				tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONNAME,
+										  CStringGetDatum(stmt->pubname));
 
-		/* Lock the publication so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-		LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
-						   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->pubname)));
 
-		/*
-		 * It is possible that by the time we acquire the lock on publication,
-		 * concurrent DDL has removed it. We can test this by checking the
-		 * existence of publication. We get the tuple again to avoid the risk
-		 * of any publication option getting changed.
-		 */
-		tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(PUBLICATIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(pubid));
-		if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-			ereport(ERROR,
-					errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-					errmsg("publication \"%s\" does not exist",
-						   stmt->pubname));
+				pubform = (Form_pg_publication) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+				pubid = pubform->oid;
+
+				if (!object_ownercheck(PublicationRelationId, pubid,
+									   GetUserId()))
+					aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_PUBLICATION,
+								   stmt->pubname);
+
+				if (retry)
+				{
+					if (pubid == oldPubId)
+						break;
+					UnlockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, oldPubId, 0,
+										 AccessExclusiveLock);
+				}
+
+				LockDatabaseObject(PublicationRelationId, pubid, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+				if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+					break;
+
+				retry = true;
+				oldPubId = pubid;
+				heap_freetuple(tup);
+			}
+		}
+
+		ObjectsInPublicationToOids(stmt->pubobjects, pstate, &relations,
+								   &exceptrelations, &schemaidlist);
+
+		CheckAlterPublication(stmt, tup, relations, schemaidlist);
 
 		relations = list_concat(relations, exceptrelations);
 		AlterPublicationTables(stmt, tup, relations, pstate->p_sourcetext,
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw--





^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread

* [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription
@ 2026-07-06 04:44  Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
  0 siblings, 0 replies; 353+ messages in thread

From: Bertrand Drouvot @ 2026-07-06 04:44 UTC (permalink / raw)

Following the approach of RangeVarGetRelidExtended() for relations, add a
retry loop that includes name resolution, ownership check, and lock
acquisition in AlterSubscription() and DropSubscription().

The loop records SharedInvalidMessageCounter, resolves the subscription name
to an OID, checks ownership, then locks the subscription. If the invalidation
counter changed (indicating concurrent DDL), we save the current OID and
retry. On the next iteration, if the name still resolves to the same OID,
we're done (already holding the correct lock). If it resolves to a different
OID, we release the old lock and acquire the new one.

This mirrors RangeVarGetRelidExtended()'s behavior: the lock is kept across
retries to avoid a window where another session could have committed concurrent
DDL modifying the ownership and/or the name resolution.

Author: Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Dilip Kumar <[email protected]>
Reviewed-by: Hayato Kuroda (Fujitsu) <[email protected]>
Discussion: https://postgr.es/m/akZUpiDa1UfmzYxL%40bdtpg
---
 src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c | 189 +++++++++++++++++-------
 1 file changed, 134 insertions(+), 55 deletions(-)
 100.0% src/backend/commands/

diff --git a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
index c9e7fbdb47b..615c3921bc3 100644
--- a/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
+++ b/src/backend/commands/subscriptioncmds.c
@@ -50,6 +50,7 @@
 #include "replication/walsender.h"
 #include "replication/worker_internal.h"
 #include "storage/lmgr.h"
+#include "storage/sinval.h"
 #include "utils/acl.h"
 #include "utils/builtins.h"
 #include "utils/guc.h"
@@ -1592,23 +1593,67 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 
 	rel = table_open(SubscriptionRelationId, RowExclusiveLock);
 
-	/* Fetch the existing tuple. */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME, ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
-							  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
+	/*
+	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it.
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
+	 */
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
+			tup = SearchSysCacheCopy2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+									  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+									  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+				ereport(ERROR,
+						(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+						 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+								stmt->subname)));
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer. So we're done. If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			heap_freetuple(tup);
+		}
+	}
 
 	/* parse and check options */
 	switch (stmt->kind)
@@ -1686,25 +1731,6 @@ AlterSubscription(ParseState *pstate, AlterSubscriptionStmt *stmt,
 			orig_conninfo_needed = false;
 	}
 
-	heap_freetuple(tup);
-
-	/* Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it. */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
-
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * DROP or ALTER may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCacheCopy1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
-
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
-
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-
 	/*
 	 * Skip ACL checks on the subscription's foreign server, if any. If
 	 * changing the server (or replacing it with a raw connection), then the
@@ -2567,38 +2593,91 @@ DropSubscription(DropSubscriptionStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel)
 		return;
 	}
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
-	subid = form->oid;
-
-	/* must be owner */
-	if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, GetUserId()))
-		aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
-					   stmt->subname);
-
 	ReleaseSysCache(tup);
 
 	/*
 	 * Lock the subscription so nobody else can do anything with it (including
 	 * the replication workers).
+	 *
+	 * Like RangeVarGetRelidExtended() does for relations, we resolve the
+	 * name, check ownership, and lock inside a loop. If invalidation messages
+	 * arrive (indicating concurrent DDL), we retry. We keep the lock held
+	 * across retries and only release it if the name resolves to a different
+	 * OID on the next iteration.
 	 */
-	LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0, AccessExclusiveLock);
+	{
+		Oid			oldSubId = InvalidOid;
+		bool		retry = false;
 
-	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
-	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
+		for (;;)
+		{
+			uint64		inval_count = SharedInvalidMessageCounter;
 
-	/*
-	 * Re-read the subscription tuple after acquiring the lock. A concurrent
-	 * ALTER or DROP may have committed before we acquired the lock.
-	 */
-	tup = SearchSysCache1(SUBSCRIPTIONOID, ObjectIdGetDatum(subid));
+			tup = SearchSysCache2(SUBSCRIPTIONNAME,
+								  ObjectIdGetDatum(MyDatabaseId),
+								  CStringGetDatum(stmt->subname));
 
-	if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
-		ereport(ERROR,
-				(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
-				 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
-						stmt->subname)));
+			if (!HeapTupleIsValid(tup))
+			{
+				if (retry)
+					UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+									   AccessExclusiveLock);
+				table_close(rel, NoLock);
+
+				if (!stmt->missing_ok)
+					ereport(ERROR,
+							(errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_OBJECT),
+							 errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist",
+									stmt->subname)));
+				else
+					ereport(NOTICE,
+							(errmsg("subscription \"%s\" does not exist, skipping",
+									stmt->subname)));
+
+				return;
+			}
+
+			form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
+			subid = form->oid;
+
+			if (!object_ownercheck(SubscriptionRelationId, subid,
+								   GetUserId()))
+			{
+				ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+				aclcheck_error(ACLCHECK_NOT_OWNER, OBJECT_SUBSCRIPTION,
+							   stmt->subname);
+			}
+
+			/*
+			 * If upon retry we get the same OID, the invalidation messages
+			 * did not change the final answer.  So we're done.  If we got a
+			 * different OID, unlock the old one and lock the new one below.
+			 */
+			if (retry)
+			{
+				if (subid == oldSubId)
+					break;
+				UnlockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, oldSubId, 0,
+								   AccessExclusiveLock);
+			}
+
+			LockSharedObject(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0,
+							 AccessExclusiveLock);
+
+			/* If no invalidation messages, we're done. */
+			if (inval_count == SharedInvalidMessageCounter)
+				break;
+
+			/* Something may have changed, retry. */
+			retry = true;
+			oldSubId = subid;
+			ReleaseSysCache(tup);
+		}
+	}
+
+	/* DROP hook for the subscription being removed */
+	InvokeObjectDropHook(SubscriptionRelationId, subid, 0);
 
-	form = (Form_pg_subscription) GETSTRUCT(tup);
 	subowner = form->subowner;
 	subserver = form->subserver;
 	subconflictlogrelid = form->subconflictlogrelid;
-- 
2.34.1


--b+bwjVhifbzgesmw
Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=us-ascii
Content-Disposition: attachment;
	filename="v4-0004-Add-invalidation-based-retry-loop-for-AlterPublic.patch"



^ permalink  raw  reply  [nested|flat] 353+ messages in thread


end of thread, other threads:[~2026-07-06 04:44 UTC | newest]

Thread overview: 353+ messages (download: mbox mbox.gz follow: Atom feed)
-- links below jump to the message on this page --
2026-04-17 17:15 [PATCH v2 1/4] pg_dump/pg_dumpall: bump minimum supported version to v10 Nathan Bossart <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:03 [PATCH v3 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v3 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-03 14:46 [PATCH v4 4/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for AlterPublication Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>
2026-07-06 04:44 [PATCH v4 3/4] Add invalidation-based retry loop for Alter/Drop Subscription Bertrand Drouvot <[email protected]>

This inbox is served by agora; see mirroring instructions
for how to clone and mirror all data and code used for this inbox